blob: c7685e4a6dd09c12cab9df24151510d5012dd94c [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000027#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000028#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000029#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000031#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000032#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000033#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000034#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000035#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000036#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000039#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000040#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000041#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000042#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000043
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000044using namespace clang;
45
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000054unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000056unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000059enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000060 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000061};
62
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000063RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000064 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000066
67#ifndef NDEBUG
68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71#endif
72
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000073 CommentsLoaded = true;
74 }
75
76 assert(D);
77
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000078 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000080 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000081
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000082 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000085 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000086 }
87
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000088 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000091 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000092 }
93
94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000096 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000097 }
98
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000099 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000104 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000105 }
106
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000109 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000110 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000115 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000116 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000119 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000120
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122 // documentation.
123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000126 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000127
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000129
130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000132 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000133
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000134 // Find declaration location.
135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137 // location".
138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000146 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152 // the "declaration location".
153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163 }
164 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000165 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000166
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000170 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000171
172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174 {
175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187 }
188
189 if (Found) {
190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193 } else {
194 // Slow path.
195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197 }
198 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199
200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201 // file buffer.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203
204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000217 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000218 }
219 }
220
221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222 // Let's look at the previous comment.
223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000224 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000225 --Comment;
226
227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000229 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000230
231 // Decompose the end of the comment.
232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000234
235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236 // aren't related.
237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000238 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000239
240 // Get the corresponding buffer.
241 bool Invalid = false;
242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243 &Invalid).data();
244 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000245 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000246
247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000254 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000255
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000257}
258
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000259namespace {
260/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000262/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000263const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000267 return FTD;
268
269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271 return D;
272
273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275 return FTD;
276
277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280 return MemberDecl;
281
282 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000283 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286 // template?
287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289 return MemberDecl;
290
291 return D;
292 }
293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296 return CTD;
297
298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299 // specialization?
300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303 return D;
304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(
310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311 }
312
313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317
318 return D;
319 }
320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323 return MemberDecl;
324
325 return D;
326 }
327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000328 return D;
329}
330} // unnamed namespace
331
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000332const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333 const Decl *D,
334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000336
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338 {
339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340 RedeclComments.find(D);
341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344 if (OriginalDecl)
345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000346 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000347 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000350
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000356 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000362 break;
363 }
364 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 if (RC) {
369 Raw.setRaw(RC);
370 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
371 } else
372 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000373 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
374 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000375 if (RC)
376 break;
377 }
378 }
379
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000380 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
381 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000382
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000383 if (OriginalDecl)
384 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
385
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000386 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
387 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
388 Raw.setRaw(RC);
389 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000390 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000391
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000392 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
393 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
395 R = Raw;
396 }
397
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000398 return RC;
399}
400
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000401static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
402 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
403 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
404 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
405 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
406 if (!ID)
407 return;
408 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000409 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000410 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000411 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000412 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
413 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
414 }
415 }
416}
417
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000418comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
419 const Decl *D) const {
420 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
421 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
422 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
423 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
424 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000425 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
426 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000427 comments::FullComment *CFC =
428 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
429 ThisDeclInfo);
430 return CFC;
431
432}
433
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000434comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
435 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000436 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000437}
438
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000439comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
440 const Decl *D,
441 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000442 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000443 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000444 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000445
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000446 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
447 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
448 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000449
450 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000451 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000452 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000453 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000454 return CFC;
455 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000456 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000457 }
458
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000459 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000460
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000461 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462 if (!RC) {
463 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000464 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000465 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000466 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
467 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
468 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
469 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000470 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000471 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
472 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000473 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
474 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
475 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000476 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000477 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000478 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000479 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000480 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000481 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
482 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
483 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000484 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000485 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000486 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
487 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
488 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
489 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
490 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
491 }
492 }
493 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
494 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
495 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
496 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
497 }
498 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
499 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000500 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000501 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000502 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
503 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000504 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000505 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000506 if (Ty.isNull())
507 continue;
508 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
509 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
510 continue;
511
512 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
513 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
514 }
515 }
516 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000517 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
518 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000519 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000520 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000521 if (Ty.isNull())
522 continue;
523 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
524 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
525 continue;
526 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
527 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
528 }
529 }
530 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000531 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000532 }
533
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000534 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
535 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
536 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
537 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000538 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000539 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000540
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000541 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000542 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
543 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000544}
545
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000546void
547ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
548 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
549 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000551 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000552
553 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
554 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
555 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
556 PEnd = Params->end();
557 P != PEnd; ++P) {
558 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
559 ID.AddInteger(0);
560 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
561 continue;
562 }
563
564 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
565 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000566 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000567 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000568 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
569 ID.AddBoolean(true);
570 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000571 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
572 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
573 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
574 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000575 } else
576 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000577 continue;
578 }
579
580 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
581 ID.AddInteger(2);
582 Profile(ID, TTP);
583 }
584}
585
586TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
587ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000588 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000589 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
590 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
591 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000592 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000593 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
594 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
595 if (Canonical)
596 return Canonical->getParam();
597
598 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
599 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000600 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000601 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
602 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
603 PEnd = Params->end();
604 P != PEnd; ++P) {
605 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
606 CanonParams.push_back(
607 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000608 SourceLocation(),
609 SourceLocation(),
610 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000611 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000612 TTP->isParameterPack()));
613 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000614 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
615 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
616 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
617 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
618 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000619 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
620 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000621 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
622 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
623 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
624 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
625 }
626
627 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000628 SourceLocation(),
629 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000630 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000631 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000632 T,
633 TInfo,
634 ExpandedTypes.data(),
635 ExpandedTypes.size(),
636 ExpandedTInfos.data());
637 } else {
638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000639 SourceLocation(),
640 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000641 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 T,
644 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645 TInfo);
646 }
647 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648
649 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652 }
653
654 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
655 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
656 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000657 TTP->getPosition(),
658 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000659 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000660 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
661 SourceLocation(),
662 CanonParams.data(),
663 CanonParams.size(),
664 SourceLocation()));
665
666 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
667 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000668 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000669 (void)Canonical;
670
671 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
672 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
673 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
674 return CanonTTP;
675}
676
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000677CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000678 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000679
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000680 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000681 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000682 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000683 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000684 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000686 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000687 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000688 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
689 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000690 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000691}
692
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000693static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000694 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
695 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
696 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
697 // language-specific address space.
698 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
699 1, // opencl_global
700 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000701 3, // opencl_constant
702 4, // cuda_device
703 5, // cuda_constant
704 6 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000705 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000706 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000707 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000708 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000709 }
710}
711
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000712static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
713 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
714 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000715 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
716 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
717 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
718 return true;
719 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
720 return false;
721 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000722 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000723}
724
Douglas Gregor7018d5b2011-09-01 20:23:19 +0000725ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions& LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000726 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000727 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000728 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()),
729 TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
730 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
731 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000732 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr),
733 Int128Decl(nullptr), UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
734 BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr),
735 ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr), ObjCClassDecl(nullptr),
736 ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
737 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr),
738 FILEDecl(nullptr),
739 jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr), ucontext_tDecl(nullptr),
740 BlockDescriptorType(nullptr), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr),
741 cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr),
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +0000742 NullTypeSourceInfo(QualType()),
743 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000744 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000745 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000746 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
747 BuiltinInfo(builtins),
748 DeclarationNames(*this),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000749 ExternalSource(nullptr), Listener(nullptr),
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000750 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Dmitri Gribenkoacf2e782013-02-22 14:21:27 +0000751 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000752 LastSDM(nullptr, 0)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000753{
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000754 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
755}
756
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000757ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000758 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
759
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000760 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
761 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
762 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000763
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000764 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
765 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
766 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
767 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
768 (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
769
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000770 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000771 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
772 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
773 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
774 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
775 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
776 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
777 R->Destroy(*this);
778
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000779 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
780 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
781 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
782 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
783 R->Destroy(*this);
784 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000785
786 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
787 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
788 A != AEnd; ++A)
789 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000790
Reid Kleckner588c9372014-02-19 23:44:52 +0000791 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000792}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000793
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000794void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
795 if (!AllParents) return;
796 for (const auto &Entry : *AllParents) {
797 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
798 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
799 } else {
800 assert(Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>());
801 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
802 }
803 }
804}
805
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000806void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000807 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000808}
809
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000810void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000811ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
812 ExternalSource = Source;
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000813}
814
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000815void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000816 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
817 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000818
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000819 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000820#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000821#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
822#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
823 0 // Extra
824 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000825
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000826 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
827 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000828 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000829 }
830
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000831 unsigned Idx = 0;
832 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
833#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
834 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000835 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
836 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000837 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
838 ++Idx;
839#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
840#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000841
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000842 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
843
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000844 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000845 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
846 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
847 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
848 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
849 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
850 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000851 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000852 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
853 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
854 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
855 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
856 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
857 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000858 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000859 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
860 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
861 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
862 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
863 << NumImplicitDestructors
864 << " implicit destructors created\n";
865
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000866 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000867 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000868 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
869 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000870
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000871 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000872}
873
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000874RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
875 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000876 SourceLocation Loc;
877 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000878 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
879 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
880 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000881 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000882 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
883 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000884 NewDecl->setImplicit();
885 return NewDecl;
886}
887
888TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
889 StringRef Name) const {
890 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
891 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
892 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
893 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
894 NewDecl->setImplicit();
895 return NewDecl;
896}
897
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000898TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000899 if (!Int128Decl)
900 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000901 return Int128Decl;
902}
903
904TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000905 if (!UInt128Decl)
906 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000907 return UInt128Decl;
908}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000909
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000910TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber5b0b46f2013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000911 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000912 if (!Float128StubDecl)
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000913 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000914
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000915 return Float128StubDecl;
916}
917
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000918void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000919 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000920 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000921 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000922}
923
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000924void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
925 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
926 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000927 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000928
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000929 this->Target = &Target;
930
931 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
932 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000933 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000934
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000935 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000936 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000937
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000938 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000939 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000940 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +0000941 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +0000942 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
943 else
944 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000945 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000946 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
947 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
948 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
949 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
950 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000951
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000952 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000953 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
954 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
955 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
956 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
957 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000958
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000959 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000960 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
961 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
962 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000963
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +0000964 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
965 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
966 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
967
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +0000968 // C++ 3.9.1p5
969 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
970 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
971 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
972 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
973 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
974 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
975 else {
976 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
977 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
978 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000979
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +0000980 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
981
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +0000982 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
983 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
984 else // C99
985 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
986
987 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
988 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
989 else // C99
990 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
991
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +0000992 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
993 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
994 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
995 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
996 // expressions.
997 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000998
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +0000999 // Placeholder type for functions.
1000 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1001
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001002 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1003 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1004
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001005 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1006 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1007
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001008 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1009 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1010
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001011 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1012 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1013
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001014 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1015 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1016
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001017 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001018 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1019 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1020 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001021
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001022 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001023 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1024 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001025 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001026
1027 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1028 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1029 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1030 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1031 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1032 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1033 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001034
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001035 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001036 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001037 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001038
1039 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001040 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1041 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001042
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001043 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001044
1045 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001046
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001047 // void * type
1048 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001049
1050 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1051 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001052
1053 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1054 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001055
1056 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1057 VaListTagTy = QualType();
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001058}
1059
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001060DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001061 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1062}
1063
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001064AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1065 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1066 if (!Result) {
1067 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1068 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1069 }
1070
1071 return *Result;
1072}
1073
1074/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1075void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1076 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1077 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1078 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1079 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1080 }
1081}
1082
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001083// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001084MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001085ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001086 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001087 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1088 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1089}
1090
1091ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1092ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1093 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1094 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1095 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1096 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001097
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001098 return Pos->second;
1099}
1100
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001101void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001102ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001103 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1104 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001105 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1106 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001107 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1108 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1109}
1110
1111void
1112ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1113 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1114 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1115 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1116 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001117}
1118
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001119FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1120 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1121 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1122 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001123 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1124 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001125 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001126
1127 return Pos->second;
1128}
1129
1130void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1131 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1132 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1133 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001134 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001135}
1136
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001137NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001138ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001139 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001140 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1141 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001142 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001143
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001144 return Pos->second;
1145}
1146
1147void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001148ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1149 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1150 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1151 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1152 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1153 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1154 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1155}
1156
1157UsingShadowDecl *
1158ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1159 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1160 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1161 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001162 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001163
1164 return Pos->second;
1165}
1166
1167void
1168ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1169 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1170 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1171 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001172}
1173
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001174FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1175 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1176 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1177 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001178 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001179
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001180 return Pos->second;
1181}
1182
1183void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1184 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1185 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1186 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1187 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1188 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001189
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001190 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1191}
1192
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001193ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1194ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1195 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001196 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001197 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001198 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001199
1200 return Pos->second.begin();
1201}
1202
1203ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1204ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1205 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001206 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001207 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001208 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001209
1210 return Pos->second.end();
1211}
1212
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001213unsigned
1214ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1215 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001216 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001217 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1218 return 0;
1219
1220 return Pos->second.size();
1221}
1222
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001223void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1224 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001225 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001226 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1227}
1228
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001229void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1230 const NamedDecl *D,
1231 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001232 assert(D);
1233
1234 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001235 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1236 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001237 return;
1238 }
1239
1240 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1241 if (!Method)
1242 return;
1243
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001244 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1245 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001246 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001247}
1248
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001249void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1250 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1251 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1252 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1253 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1254 LastLocalImport = Import;
1255 return;
1256 }
1257
1258 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1259 LastLocalImport = Import;
1260}
1261
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001262//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1263// Type Sizing and Analysis
1264//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001265
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001266/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1267/// scalar floating point type.
1268const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001269 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001270 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1271 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001272 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001273 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001274 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1275 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1276 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001277 }
1278}
1279
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001280CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001281 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001282
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001283 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1284 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1285 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001286
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001287 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1288 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1289 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1290 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001291 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001292 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1293 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1294 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1295 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1296 } else {
1297 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1298 }
1299 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001300 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1301 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1302 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1303 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001304
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001305 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1306 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001307 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001308 // do nothing
1309
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001310 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001311 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001312 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001313 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001314 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1315 else
1316 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1317 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001318 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1319 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001320 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1321 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001322 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001323 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1324 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001325 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1326 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1327 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1328 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1329 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1330 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001331 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001332 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001333 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1334 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage())
1335 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1336 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001337 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001338
1339 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1340 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1341 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1342 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1343 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001344 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1345 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1346 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1347 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1348 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001349
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001350 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1351 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001352
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001353 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1354 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1355 if (Offset > 0) {
1356 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1357 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1358 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1359 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1360 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1361 }
1362
1363 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001364 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001365 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001366 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001367
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001368 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001369}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001370
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001371// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1372// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1373// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1374// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1375std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1376ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1377 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1378
1379 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1380 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1381 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1382 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1383 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1384 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1385 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1386 }
1387 }
1388
1389 return sizeAndAlign;
1390}
1391
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001392/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1393/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1394std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1395static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1396 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1397 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1398 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1399 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001400 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1401 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001402 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1403 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1404 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001405 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1406 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1407 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001408 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1409 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1410}
1411
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001412std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001413ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001414 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1415 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001416 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1417 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1418 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001419}
1420
1421std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001422ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001423 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1424}
1425
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001426bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1427 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1428}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001429
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001430bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1431 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1432}
1433
1434TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1435 TypeInfo &TI = MemoizedTypeInfo[T];
1436 if (!TI.Align)
1437 TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1438
1439 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001440}
1441
1442/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1443/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001444///
1445/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1446/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1447/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001448TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1449 uint64_t Width = 0;
1450 unsigned Align = 8;
1451 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001452 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001453#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1454#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001455#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001456#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001457#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1458 case Type::Class: \
1459 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1460 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001461#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001462 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001463
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001464 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1465 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001466 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1467 Width = 0;
1468 Align = 32;
1469 break;
1470
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001471 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001472 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001473 Width = 0;
1474 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1475 break;
1476
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001477 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001478 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001479
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001480 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001481 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001482 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001483 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001484 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1485 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001486 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1487 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1488 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001489 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001490 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001491 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001492 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001493 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001494 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1495 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001496 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001497 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1498 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001499 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001500 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1501 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1502 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001503 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1504 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1505 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1506 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001507 break;
1508 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001509
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001510 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001511 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001512 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001513 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001514 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1515 Width = 0;
1516 Align = 8;
1517 break;
1518
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001519 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001520 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1521 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001522 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001523 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1524 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1525 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001526 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001527 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1528 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001529 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001530 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1531 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001532 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1533 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001534 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001535 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001536 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1537 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001538 break;
1539 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001540 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1541 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001542 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001543 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001544 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001545 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1546 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001547 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001548 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001549 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001550 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1551 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001552 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001553 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001554 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001555 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1556 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001557 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001558 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001559 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001560 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1561 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001562 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001563 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1564 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1565 Width = 128;
1566 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1567 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001568 case BuiltinType::Half:
1569 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1570 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1571 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001572 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001573 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1574 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001575 break;
1576 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001577 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1578 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001579 break;
1580 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001581 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1582 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001583 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001584 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001585 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1586 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001587 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001588 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1589 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1590 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001591 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1592 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001593 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001594 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1595 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1596 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1597 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1598 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001599 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001600 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1601 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1602 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1603 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1604 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1605 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1606 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1607 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1608 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1609 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001610 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001611 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001612 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001613 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1614 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001615 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001616 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001617 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1618 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001619 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1620 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001621 break;
1622 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001623 case Type::LValueReference:
1624 case Type::RValueReference: {
1625 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1626 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001627 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1628 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001629 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1630 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001631 break;
1632 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001633 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001634 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001635 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1636 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001637 break;
1638 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001639 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001640 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001641 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001642 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001643 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001644 case Type::Complex: {
1645 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1646 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001647 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1648 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1649 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001650 break;
1651 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001652 case Type::ObjCObject:
1653 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001654 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001655 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001656 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001657 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001658 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001659 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001660 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001661 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001662 break;
1663 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001664 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001665 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001666 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1667
1668 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001669 Width = 8;
1670 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001671 break;
1672 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001673
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001674 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT))
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001675 return getTypeInfo(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType());
1676
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001677 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001678 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001679 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001680 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001681 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001682 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001683
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001684 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001685 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1686 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001687
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001688 case Type::Auto: {
1689 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001690 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1691 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001692 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001693 }
1694
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001695 case Type::Paren:
1696 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1697
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001698 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001699 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001700 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001701 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1702 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1703 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001704 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001705 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001706 AlignIsRequired = true;
1707 } else
1708 Align = Info.Align;
1709 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001710 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001711 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001712
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001713 case Type::Elaborated:
1714 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001715
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001716 case Type::Attributed:
1717 return getTypeInfo(
1718 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1719
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001720 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001721 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001722 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1723 Width = Info.Width;
1724 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001725
1726 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1727 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1728 // favorable to atomic operations:
1729 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1730 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1731 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1732 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1733
1734 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001735 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1736 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001737 }
1738
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001739 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001740
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001741 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001742 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001743}
1744
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001745/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1746CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1747 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1748}
1749
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001750/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1751int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1752 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1753}
1754
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001755/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1756/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001757CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001758 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001759}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001760CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001761 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001762}
1763
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001764/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001765/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001766CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001767 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001768}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001769CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001770 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001771}
1772
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001773/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1774/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1775/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1776/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001777unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001778 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1779 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001780
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001781 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1782 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore.
1783
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001784 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
Richard Smithd7e1fe42014-06-10 23:43:44 +00001785 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00001786 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001787 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1788 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001789 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1790 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001791 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1792 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001793 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001794 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001795
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001796 return ABIAlign;
1797}
1798
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001799/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1800/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1801unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1802 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1803}
1804
1805/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1806/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1807CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1808 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1809}
1810
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001811/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1812/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1813/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1814/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1815/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001816///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001817void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1818 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001819 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001820 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1821 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1822 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00001823 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1824 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001825 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001826 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001827 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001828 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1829 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1830 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001831}
1832
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001833/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1834/// those inherited by it.
1835void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001836 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001837 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001838 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1839 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00001840 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001841 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001842 for (auto *P : Proto->protocols()) {
1843 Protocols.insert(P->getCanonicalDecl());
1844 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001845 }
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001846 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001847
1848 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00001849 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1850 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001851
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001852 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1853 while (SD) {
1854 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1855 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1856 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001857 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00001858 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001859 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001860 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1861 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001862 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001863 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001864 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001865 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001866 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1867 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001868 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001869 }
1870}
1871
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001872unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001873 unsigned count = 0;
1874 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00001875 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001876 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001877
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001878 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1879 // includes synthesized ivars.
1880 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001881 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1882
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00001883 return count;
1884}
1885
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00001886bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1887 if (!E)
1888 return false;
1889
1890 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1891 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1892
1893 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1894 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1895 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1896 return true;
1897
1898 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1899 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1900
1901 return false;
1902}
1903
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001904/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1905ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1906 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1907 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1908 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1909 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001910 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001911}
1912/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1913ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1914 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1915 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1916 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1917 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001918 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001919}
1920
1921/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
1922void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1923 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1924 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1925 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
1926}
1927/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
1928void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
1929 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
1930 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1931 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
1932}
1933
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001934const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
1935 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
1936 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
1937 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001938 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001939 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
1940 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001941 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001942 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
1943 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001944 return IMD->getClassInterface();
1945
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001946 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001947}
1948
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001949/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
1950/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001951Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001952 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
1953 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1954 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001955 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001956 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001957 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001958}
1959
1960/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
1961void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
1962 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001963 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1964 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001965 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
1966}
1967
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001968TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001969 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001970 if (!DataSize)
1971 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
1972 else
1973 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001974 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001975
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001976 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
1977 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
1978 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
1979 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00001980}
1981
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001982TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00001983 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001984 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00001985 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00001986 return DI;
1987}
1988
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001989const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001990ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001991 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001992}
1993
1994const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001995ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
1996 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001997 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
1998}
1999
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002000//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2001// Type creation/memoization methods
2002//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2003
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002004QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002005ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2006 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2007 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002008
2009 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2010 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002011 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002012 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002013 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2014 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2015 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002016 }
2017
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002018 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2019 QualType canon;
2020 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2021 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002022 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2023 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002024
2025 // Re-find the insert position.
2026 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2027 }
2028
2029 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2030 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2031 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002032}
2033
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002034QualType
2035ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002036 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2037 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002038 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002039
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002040 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2041 // into one ExtQuals node.
2042 QualifierCollector Quals;
2043 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002044
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002045 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2046 // another one.
2047 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2048 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2049 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002050
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002051 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002052}
2053
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002054QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002055 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002056 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002057 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002058 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002059
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002060 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2061 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002062 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002063 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2064 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2065 }
2066 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002067
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002068 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2069 // into one ExtQuals node.
2070 QualifierCollector Quals;
2071 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002072
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002073 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2074 // another one.
2075 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2076 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2077 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002078
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002079 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002080}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002081
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002082const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2083 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2084 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2085 return T;
2086
2087 QualType Result;
2088 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002089 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002090 } else {
2091 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2092 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2093 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002094 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002095 }
2096
2097 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2098}
2099
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002100void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2101 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002102 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2103 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002104 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2105 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002106 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002107 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2108 FD = Next;
2109 else
2110 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002111 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002112 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2113 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002114}
2115
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002116/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2117/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002118QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002119 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2120 // structure.
2121 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2122 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002123
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002124 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002125 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2126 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002127
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002128 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2129 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2130 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002131 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002132 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002133
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002134 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2135 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002136 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002137 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002138 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002139 Types.push_back(New);
2140 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2141 return QualType(New, 0);
2142}
2143
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002144/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2145/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002146QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002147 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2148 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002149 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002150 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002151
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002152 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002153 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002154 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002156 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2157 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002158 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002159 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002160 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002161
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002162 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2163 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002164 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002165 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002166 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002167 Types.push_back(New);
2168 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002169 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002170}
2171
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002172QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2173 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2174 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002175 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002176 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2177 if (AT)
2178 return QualType(AT, 0);
2179
2180 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2181
2182 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2183 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002184 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002185
2186 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2187 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2188 Types.push_back(AT);
2189 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2190 return QualType(AT, 0);
2191}
2192
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002193QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2194 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2195
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002196 QualType Decayed;
2197
2198 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2199 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2200 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2201 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2202 // the array type derivation.
2203 if (T->isArrayType())
2204 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2205
2206 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2207 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2208 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2209 // in 6.3.2.1.
2210 if (T->isFunctionType())
2211 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2212
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002213 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2214 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002215 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002216 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2217 if (AT)
2218 return QualType(AT, 0);
2219
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002220 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2221
2222 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002223 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002224 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002225
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002226 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2227 Types.push_back(AT);
2228 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2229 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002230}
2231
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002232/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002233/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002234QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002235 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2236 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002237 // structure.
2238 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2239 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002240
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002241 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002242 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2243 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2244 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002245
2246 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002247 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2248 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002249 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002250 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002251
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002252 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2253 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2254 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002255 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002256 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002257 BlockPointerType *New
2258 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002259 Types.push_back(New);
2260 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2261 return QualType(New, 0);
2262}
2263
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002264/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2265/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002266QualType
2267ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002268 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2269 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2270
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002271 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2272 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002273 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002274 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002275
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002276 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002277 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2278 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002279 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002280
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002281 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2282
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002283 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2284 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2285 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002286 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2287 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2288 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002289
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002290 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002291 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2292 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002293 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002294 }
2295
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002296 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002297 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2298 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002299 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002300 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002301
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002302 return QualType(New, 0);
2303}
2304
2305/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2306/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002307QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002308 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2309 // structure.
2310 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002311 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002312
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002313 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002314 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2315 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2316 return QualType(RT, 0);
2317
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002318 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2319
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002320 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2321 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2322 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002323 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2324 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2325 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002326
2327 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2328 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2329 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002330 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002331 }
2332
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002333 RValueReferenceType *New
2334 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002335 Types.push_back(New);
2336 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002337 return QualType(New, 0);
2338}
2339
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002340/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2341/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002342QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002343 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2344 // structure.
2345 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2346 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2347
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002348 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002349 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2350 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2351 return QualType(PT, 0);
2352
2353 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2354 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2355 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002356 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002357 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2358
2359 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2360 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2361 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002362 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002363 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002364 MemberPointerType *New
2365 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002366 Types.push_back(New);
2367 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2368 return QualType(New, 0);
2369}
2370
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002371/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002372/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002373QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002374 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002375 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002376 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002377 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2378 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002379 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2380
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002381 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2382 // the target.
2383 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002384 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002385 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002386
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002387 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002388 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002389
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002390 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002391 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002392 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002393 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002394
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002395 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2396 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2397 QualType Canon;
2398 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2399 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002400 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002401 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002402 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002403
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002404 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002405 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002406 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002407 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002408 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002409
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002410 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002411 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002412 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002413 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002414 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002415}
2416
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002417/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2418/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2419/// sizes replaced with [*].
2420QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2421 // Vastly most common case.
2422 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002423
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002424 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002425
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002426 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002427 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002428 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2429#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2430#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2431#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2432#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2433 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2434
2435 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2436 case Type::Builtin:
2437 case Type::Complex:
2438 case Type::Vector:
2439 case Type::ExtVector:
2440 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2441 case Type::ObjCObject:
2442 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2443 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2444 case Type::Record:
2445 case Type::Enum:
2446 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2447 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2448 case Type::TypeOf:
2449 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002450 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002451 case Type::DependentName:
2452 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2453 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2454 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2455 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2456 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002457 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002458 case Type::PackExpansion:
2459 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2460
2461 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2462 // further decay.
2463 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2464 case Type::FunctionProto:
2465 case Type::BlockPointer:
2466 case Type::MemberPointer:
2467 return type;
2468
2469 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2470 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2471 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2472 // optimizations available here.
2473 case Type::Pointer:
2474 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2475 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2476 break;
2477
2478 case Type::LValueReference: {
2479 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2480 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2481 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2482 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2483 break;
2484 }
2485
2486 case Type::RValueReference: {
2487 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2488 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2489 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2490 break;
2491 }
2492
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002493 case Type::Atomic: {
2494 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2495 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2496 break;
2497 }
2498
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002499 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2500 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2501 result = getConstantArrayType(
2502 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2503 cat->getSize(),
2504 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2505 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2506 break;
2507 }
2508
2509 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2510 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2511 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2512 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2513 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2514 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2515 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2516 dat->getBracketsRange());
2517 break;
2518 }
2519
2520 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2521 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2522 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2523 result = getVariableArrayType(
2524 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002525 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002526 ArrayType::Normal,
2527 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2528 SourceRange());
2529 break;
2530 }
2531
2532 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2533 case Type::VariableArray: {
2534 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2535 result = getVariableArrayType(
2536 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002537 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002538 ArrayType::Star,
2539 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2540 vat->getBracketsRange());
2541 break;
2542 }
2543 }
2544
2545 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002546 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002547}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002548
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002549/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2550/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002551QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2552 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002553 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002554 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002555 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002556 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2557 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002558 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002559
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002560 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2561 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2562 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002563 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002564 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002565 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002566 }
2567
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002568 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002569 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002570
2571 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2572 Types.push_back(New);
2573 return QualType(New, 0);
2574}
2575
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002576/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2577/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002578/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002579QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2580 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002581 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002582 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2583 SourceRange brackets) const {
2584 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2585 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002586 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2587
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002588 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2589 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2590 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2591 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2592 if (!numElements) {
2593 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2594 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2595 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2596 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2597 brackets);
2598 Types.push_back(newType);
2599 return QualType(newType, 0);
2600 }
2601
2602 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2603 // also build a canonical type.
2604
2605 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2606
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002607 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002608 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002609 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002610 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002611 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002612
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002613 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2614 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2615 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002616
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002617 // If we don't have one, build one.
2618 if (!canonTy) {
2619 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002620 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002621 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2622 brackets);
2623 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2624 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002625 }
2626
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002627 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2628 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002629 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002630
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002631 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2632 // then just use that as our result.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002633 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002634 return canon;
2635
2636 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2637 // of the element type.
2638 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2639 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2640 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2641 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2642 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2643 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002644}
2645
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002646QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002647 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002648 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002649 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002650 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002651
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002652 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002653 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2654 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2655 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002656
2657 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002658 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2659 // qualifiers off the element type.
2660 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002661
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002662 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2663 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002664 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002665 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002666 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002667
2668 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002669 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2670 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2671 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002672 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002673
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002674 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2675 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002676
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002677 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2678 Types.push_back(newType);
2679 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002680}
2681
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002682/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2683/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002684QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002685 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002686 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002687
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002688 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2689 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002690 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002691
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002692 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002693 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2694 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2695
2696 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2697 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2698 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002699 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002700 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002701
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002702 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2703 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002704 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002705 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002706 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002707 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002708 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2709 Types.push_back(New);
2710 return QualType(New, 0);
2711}
2712
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002713/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002714/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002715QualType
2716ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002717 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002718
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002719 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2720 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002721 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002722 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002723 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002724 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2725 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2726
2727 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2728 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2729 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002730 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002731 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002732
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002733 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2734 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002735 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002736 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002737 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2738 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002739 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2740 Types.push_back(New);
2741 return QualType(New, 0);
2742}
2743
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002744QualType
2745ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2746 Expr *SizeExpr,
2747 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002748 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002749 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002750 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002751
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002752 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002753 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2754 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2755 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2756 if (Canon) {
2757 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2758 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002759 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2760 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2761 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002762 } else {
2763 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2764 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002765 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2766 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2767 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002768
2769 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2770 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2771 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2772 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002773 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2774 } else {
2775 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2776 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002777 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2778 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002779 }
2780 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002781
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002782 Types.push_back(New);
2783 return QualType(New, 0);
2784}
2785
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002786/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002787///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002788QualType
2789ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2790 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002791 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2792
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002793 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2794 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002795 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002796 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002797
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002798 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002799 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002800 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002801 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002802
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002803 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002804 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2805 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002806
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002807 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002808 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2809 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002810 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002811 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002812
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002813 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002814 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002815 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002816 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002817 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002818 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002819}
2820
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002821/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2822static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2823 return T.isCanonical() &&
2824 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2825 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2826}
2827
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002828QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002829ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002830 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002831 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2832
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002833 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2834 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002835 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002836 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2837 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002838
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002839 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002840 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002841 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002842 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002843
2844 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002845 bool isCanonical =
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002846 EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002847 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002848 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002849 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002850 isCanonical = false;
2851
2852 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002853 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002854 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002855 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002856 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002857 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2858 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002859 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002860
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002861 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002862 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Sebastian Redl7c6c9e92011-03-06 10:52:04 +00002863 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpecType = EST_None;
2864 CanonicalEPI.NumExceptions = 0;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002865
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002866 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2867 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2868 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2869 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
2870 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
2871 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2872 }
2873
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002874 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002875
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002876 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002877 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
2878 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002879 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002880 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002881
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002882 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
2883 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
2884 // - parameter types
2885 // - exception types
2886 // - consumed-arguments flags
2887 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002888 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
2889 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002890 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002891 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002892 if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Dynamic) {
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002893 Size += EPI.NumExceptions * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002894 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00002895 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +00002896 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00002897 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002898 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Unevaluated) {
2899 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002900 }
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00002901 if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002902 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
2903
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002904 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002905 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002906 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002907 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002908 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002909 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002910}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00002911
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002912#ifndef NDEBUG
2913static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
2914 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
2915 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
2916 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2917 return true;
2918 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
2919 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2920 return true;
2921 return false;
2922}
2923#endif
2924
2925/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
2926/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
2927QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002928 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002929 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
2930 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
2931 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002932 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002933 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
2934 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
2935 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
2936 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002937 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00002938 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002939 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2940 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002941 }
2942 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2943}
2944
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002945/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
2946/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002947QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00002948 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002949 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002950
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002951 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002952 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002953
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002954 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
2955 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
2956
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002957 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002958 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002959 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002960 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002961 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002962 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002963 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002964 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00002965 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002966 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
2967 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2968 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00002969 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002970 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002971
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002972 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002973}
2974
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00002975/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002976/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002977QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002978ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2979 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002980 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002981
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002982 if (Canonical.isNull())
2983 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002984 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002985 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002986 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2987 Types.push_back(newType);
2988 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00002989}
2990
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002991QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002992 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2993
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002994 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002995 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2996 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2997
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002998 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
2999 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3000 Types.push_back(newType);
3001 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003002}
3003
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003004QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003005 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3006
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003007 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003008 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3009 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3010
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003011 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3012 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3013 Types.push_back(newType);
3014 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003015}
3016
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003017QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3018 QualType modifiedType,
3019 QualType equivalentType) {
3020 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3021 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3022
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003023 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003024 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3025 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3026
3027 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3028 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3029 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3030
3031 Types.push_back(type);
3032 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3033
3034 return QualType(type, 0);
3035}
3036
3037
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003038/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3039QualType
3040ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003041 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003042 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003043 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3044
3045 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3046 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003047 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003048 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3049 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3050
3051 if (!SubstParm) {
3052 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3053 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3054 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3055 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3056 }
3057
3058 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3059}
3060
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003061/// \brief Retrieve a
3062QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3063 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3064 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3065#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003066 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3067 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3068 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003069 }
3070#endif
3071
3072 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3073 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003074 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003075 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3076 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3077 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3078
3079 QualType Canon;
3080 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3081 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3082 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3083 ArgPack);
3084 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3085 }
3086
3087 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3088 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3089 ArgPack);
3090 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3091 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3092 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3093}
3094
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003095/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003096/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003097/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003098QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003099 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003100 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003101 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003102 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003103 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003104 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003105 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3106
3107 if (TypeParm)
3108 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003109
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003110 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003111 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003112 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003113
3114 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3115 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3116 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3117 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003118 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003119 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3120 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003121
3122 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3123 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3124
3125 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3126}
3127
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003128TypeSourceInfo *
3129ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3130 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3131 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003132 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003133 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3134 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003135 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003136
3137 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003138 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3139 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003140 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003141 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3142 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3143 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3144 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3145 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3146 return DI;
3147}
3148
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003149QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003150ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003151 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003152 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003153 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3154 "No dependent template names here!");
3155
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003156 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3157
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003158 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003159 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3160 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3161 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3162
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003163 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003164 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003165}
3166
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003167#ifndef NDEBUG
3168static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3169 unsigned NumArgs) {
3170 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3171 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3172 return true;
3173
3174 return true;
3175}
3176#endif
3177
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003178QualType
3179ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003180 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3181 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003182 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003183 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3184 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003185 // Look through qualified template names.
3186 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3187 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003188
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003189 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003190 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3191 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003192 QualType CanonType;
3193 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3194 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3195 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003196 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3197 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3198 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3199 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3200 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003201 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3202 NumArgs);
3203 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003204
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003205 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3206 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3207 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003208 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3209 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003210 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003211 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003212 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003213 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3214 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003215
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003216 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003217 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003218}
3219
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003220QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003221ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3222 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003223 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003224 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3225 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003226
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003227 // Look through qualified template names.
3228 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3229 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003230
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003231 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3232 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003233 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003234 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3235 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3236 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3237
3238 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3239 // exists.
3240 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3241 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3242 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3243
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003244 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003245 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3246 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3247
3248 if (!Spec) {
3249 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3250 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3251 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3252 TypeAlignment);
3253 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3254 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003255 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003256 Types.push_back(Spec);
3257 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3258 }
3259
3260 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3261 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3262 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3263}
3264
3265QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003266ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3267 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003268 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003269 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003270 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003271
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003272 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003273 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003274 if (T)
3275 return QualType(T, 0);
3276
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003277 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3278 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3279 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003280 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3281 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003282 (void)CheckT;
3283 }
3284
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003285 T = new (*this) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003286 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003287 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003288 return QualType(T, 0);
3289}
3290
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003291QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003292ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003293 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3294 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3295
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003296 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003297 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3298 if (T)
3299 return QualType(T, 0);
3300
3301 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3302 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3303 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3304 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3305 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3306 (void)CheckT;
3307 }
3308
3309 T = new (*this) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3310 Types.push_back(T);
3311 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3312 return QualType(T, 0);
3313}
3314
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003315QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3316 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3317 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003318 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003319 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3320 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003321 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3322 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3323 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3324
3325 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3326 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003327 }
3328
3329 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003330 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003331
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003332 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003333 DependentNameType *T
3334 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003335 if (T)
3336 return QualType(T, 0);
3337
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003338 T = new (*this) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003339 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003340 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003341 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003342}
3343
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003344QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003345ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3346 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003347 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003348 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003349 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003350 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003351 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003352 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3353 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3354 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3355 ArgCopy.size(),
3356 ArgCopy.data());
3357}
3358
3359QualType
3360ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3361 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3362 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3363 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3364 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003365 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003366 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3367 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003368
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003369 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003370 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3371 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003372
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003373 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003374 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3375 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003376 if (T)
3377 return QualType(T, 0);
3378
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003379 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003380
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003381 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3382 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3383
3384 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003385 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003386 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3387 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3388 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3389 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003390 }
3391
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003392 QualType Canon;
3393 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3394 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3395 Name, NumArgs,
3396 CanonArgs.data());
3397
3398 // Find the insert position again.
3399 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3400 }
3401
3402 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3403 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3404 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003405 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003406 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003407 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003408 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003409 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003410}
3411
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003412QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003413 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003414 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003415 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003416
3417 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3418 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003419 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003420 PackExpansionType *T
3421 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3422 if (T)
3423 return QualType(T, 0);
3424
3425 QualType Canon;
3426 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003427 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3428 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3429 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3430 // parameters.
3431 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003432 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003433
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003434 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3435 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3436 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3437 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003438 }
3439
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003440 T = new (*this) PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003441 Types.push_back(T);
3442 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003443 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003444}
3445
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003446/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3447/// alphabetically.
3448static bool CmpProtocolNames(const ObjCProtocolDecl *LHS,
3449 const ObjCProtocolDecl *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor77324f32008-11-17 14:58:09 +00003450 return LHS->getDeclName() < RHS->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003451}
3452
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003453static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003454 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3455 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3456
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003457 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3458 return false;
3459
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003460 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003461 if (!CmpProtocolNames(Protocols[i-1], Protocols[i]) ||
3462 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003463 return false;
3464 return true;
3465}
3466
3467static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003468 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3469 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003470
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003471 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3472 std::sort(Protocols, Protocols+NumProtocols, CmpProtocolNames);
3473
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003474 // Canonicalize.
3475 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3476 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3477
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003478 // Remove duplicates.
3479 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3480 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3481}
3482
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003483QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3484 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003485 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003486 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3487 // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3488 if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3489 return BaseType;
3490
3491 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003492 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003493 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003494 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003495 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3496 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003497
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003498 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3499 // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003500 QualType Canonical;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003501 bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3502 if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3503 if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003504 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00003505 Protocols + NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003506 unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3507
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003508 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003509 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3510 &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003511 } else {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003512 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3513 Protocols, NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003514 }
3515
3516 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003517 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3518 }
3519
3520 unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3521 Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3522 void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3523 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3524 new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3525
3526 Types.push_back(T);
3527 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3528 return QualType(T, 0);
3529}
3530
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003531/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3532/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3533/// list.
3534bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3535 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3536 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3537 return false;
3538
3539 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3540 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003541 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003542 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3543 return false;
3544 }
3545 return true;
3546 }
3547 return false;
3548}
3549
3550/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3551/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3552/// of protocols.
3553bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3554 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3555 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3556 return false;
3557 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3558 if (!OPT)
3559 return false;
3560 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3561 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003562 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3563 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3564 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3565 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003566 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3567 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3568 bool Conforms = false;
3569 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3570 Conforms = false;
3571 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3572 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3573 Conforms = true;
3574 break;
3575 }
3576 }
3577 if (!Conforms)
3578 break;
3579 }
3580 if (Conforms)
3581 return true;
3582
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003583 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003584 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3585 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003586 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003587 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003588 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003589 break;
3590 }
3591 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003592 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003593 }
3594 return true;
3595}
3596
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003597/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3598/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003599QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003600 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3601 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3602
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003603 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003604 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3605 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3606 return QualType(QT, 0);
3607
3608 // Find the canonical object type.
3609 QualType Canonical;
3610 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3611 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3612
3613 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003614 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3615 }
3616
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003617 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003618 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3619 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3620 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003621
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003622 Types.push_back(QType);
3623 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003624 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003625}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003626
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003627/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3628/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003629QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3630 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003631 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3632 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003633
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003634 if (PrevDecl) {
3635 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3636 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3637 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3638 }
3639
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003640 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3641 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3642 Decl = Def;
3643
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003644 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3645 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3646 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3647 Types.push_back(T);
3648 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003649}
3650
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003651/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3652/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003653/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003654/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003655/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003656QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003657 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003658 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3659 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3660 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003661
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003662 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003663 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3664 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3665 if (Canon) {
3666 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3667 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003668 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003669 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003670 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003671 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003672 Canon
3673 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003674 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3675 toe = Canon;
3676 }
3677 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003678 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003679 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003680 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003681 Types.push_back(toe);
3682 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003683}
3684
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003685/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003686/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003687/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003688/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3689/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003690QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003691 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003692 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003693 Types.push_back(tot);
3694 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003695}
3696
Anders Carlssonad6bd352009-06-24 21:24:56 +00003697
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003698/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3699/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3700/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3701/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003702QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003703 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003704
3705 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003706 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003707 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3708 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003709 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003710 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3711 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003712
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003713 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003714 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3715 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003716 if (!Canon) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003717 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003718 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003719 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003720 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003721 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3722 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003723 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003724 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3725 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003726 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003727 Types.push_back(dt);
3728 return QualType(dt, 0);
3729}
3730
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003731/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3732/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3733QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3734 QualType UnderlyingType,
3735 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3736 const {
3737 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003738 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3739 Kind,
3740 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003741 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003742 Types.push_back(Ty);
3743 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3744}
3745
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003746/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3747/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3748/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3749QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003750 bool IsDependent) const {
3751 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003752 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003753
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003754 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003755 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003756 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003757 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003758 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3759 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003760
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00003761 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003762 IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003763 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003764 Types.push_back(AT);
3765 if (InsertPos)
3766 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3767 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00003768}
3769
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003770/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3771/// the given value type.
3772QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3773 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3774 // structure.
3775 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3776 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3777
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003778 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003779 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3780 return QualType(AT, 0);
3781
3782 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3783 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3784 QualType Canonical;
3785 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3786 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3787
3788 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3789 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003790 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003791 }
3792 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3793 Types.push_back(New);
3794 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3795 return QualType(New, 0);
3796}
3797
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003798/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3799QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3800 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003801 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3802 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003803 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003804 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003805 return AutoDeductTy;
3806}
3807
3808/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3809QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3810 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3811 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3812 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3813 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3814}
3815
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003816/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3817/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003818QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00003819 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00003820 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3821 // away const? mutable?
3822 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003823}
3824
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003825/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3826/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3827/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00003828CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003829 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00003830}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003831
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003832/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3833CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3834 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3835}
3836
3837/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3838CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3839 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3840}
3841
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00003842/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3843/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3844QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3845 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3846 return WCharTy;
3847}
3848
3849/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3850/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3851QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3852 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3853 return UnsignedIntTy;
3854}
3855
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00003856QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3857 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3858}
3859
3860QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3861 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3862}
3863
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003864/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003865/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
3866QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003867 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003868}
3869
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00003870/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
3871/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
3872QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
3873 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
3874}
3875
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00003876//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3877// Type Operators
3878//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3879
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003880CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003881 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
3882 // qualifiers.
3883 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003884 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003885 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003886 QualType Result;
3887 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
3888 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
3889 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
3890 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
3891 } else {
3892 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
3893 }
3894
3895 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
3896}
3897
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003898QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
3899 Qualifiers &quals) {
3900 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
3901
3902 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
3903 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
3904 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
3905 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
3906 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003907 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003908
3909 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003910 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003911 quals = splitType.Quals;
3912 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003913 }
3914
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003915 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
3916 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
3917 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
3918
3919 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
3920 // can just use the results in splitType.
3921 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
3922 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003923 quals = splitType.Quals;
3924 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003925 }
3926
3927 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
3928 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003929 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003930
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003931 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003932 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003933 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
3934 }
3935
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003936 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003937 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003938 }
3939
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003940 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003941 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00003942 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003943 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
3944 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3945 VAT->getBracketsRange());
3946 }
3947
3948 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003949 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003950 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
3951 SourceRange());
3952}
3953
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003954/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
3955/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
3956/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
3957/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
3958/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
3959/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
3960/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
3961/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
3962bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
3963 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
3964 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
3965 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
3966 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
3967 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
3968 return true;
3969 }
3970
3971 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
3972 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3973 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
3974 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
3975 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
3976 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
3977 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
3978 return true;
3979 }
3980
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003981 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003982 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
3983 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3984 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
3985 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
3986 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
3987 return true;
3988 }
3989 }
3990
3991 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
3992
3993 return false;
3994}
3995
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003996DeclarationNameInfo
3997ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
3998 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003999 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4000 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4001 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004002 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004003 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4004 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004005
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004006 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4007 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4008 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4009 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4010 }
4011
4012 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4013 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004014 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004015 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004016 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4017 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004018 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004019 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4020 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4021 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4022 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4023 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4024 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004025 }
4026 }
4027
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004028 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4029 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4030 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4031 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4032 NameLoc);
4033 }
4034
4035 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4036 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4037 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4038 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4039 NameLoc);
4040 }
4041 }
4042
4043 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004044}
4045
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004046TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004047 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4048 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4049 case TemplateName::Template: {
4050 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004051 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004052 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004053 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4054
4055 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004056 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004057 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004058
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004059 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4060 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004061
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004062 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4063 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4064 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4065 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4066 }
4067
4068 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4069 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4070 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4071 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4072 }
4073
4074 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4075 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4076 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4077 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4078 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4079 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4080 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4081 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4082 }
4083 }
4084
4085 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004086}
4087
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004088bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4089 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4090 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4091 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4092}
4093
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004094TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004095ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004096 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4097 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4098 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004099
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004100 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004101 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004102
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004103 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004104 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
4105 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.isDeclForReferenceParam());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004106 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004107
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004108 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4109 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4110 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4111
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004112 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4113 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004114
4115 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4116 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4117 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004118 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004119
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004120 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004121 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004122
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004123 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004124 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004125
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004126 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004127 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4128 return Arg;
4129
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004130 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4131 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004132 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004133 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004134 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4135 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4136 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004137
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004138 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004139 }
4140 }
4141
4142 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004143 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004144}
4145
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004146NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004147ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004148 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004149 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004150
4151 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4152 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4153 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004154 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004155 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4156 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4157
4158 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4159 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4160 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004161 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004162 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4163
4164 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4165 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4166 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004167 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004168 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4169 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004170
4171 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4172 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4173 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004174
4175 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4176 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4177 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4178 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4179 // types, e.g.,
4180 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4181 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004182 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4183 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004184 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004185
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004186 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4187 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4188 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004189 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4190 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004191 }
4192
4193 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4194 // The global specifier is canonical and unique.
4195 return NNS;
4196 }
4197
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004198 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004199}
4200
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004201
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004202const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004203 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004204 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004205 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4206 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4207 return AT;
4208 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004209
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004210 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004211 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004212 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004213
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004214 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004215 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4216 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004217
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004218 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4219 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004220 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004221
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004222 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004223 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004224
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004225 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004226 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004227 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004228 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004229
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004230 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4231 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004232 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004233
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004234 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4235 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4236 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004237 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004238 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4239 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4240 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004241 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004242
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004243 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004244 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4245 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004246 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004247 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004248 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004249 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004250 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004251
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004252 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004253 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004254 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004255 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004256 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004257 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004258}
4259
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004260QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004261 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4262 return getDecayedType(T);
4263 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004264}
4265
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004266QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004267 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4268 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4269 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4270}
4271
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004272/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4273/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4274/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4275/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4276///
4277/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004278QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004279 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4280 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4281 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4282 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4283 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4284 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004285
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004286 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004287
4288 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004289 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004290}
4291
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004292QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4293 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004294}
4295
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004296QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4297 Qualifiers qs;
4298 while (true) {
4299 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004300 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004301 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004302
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004303 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004304 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004305 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004306
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004307 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004308}
4309
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004310/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004311uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004312ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4313 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4314 do {
4315 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004316 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4317 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004318 } while (CA);
4319 return ElementCount;
4320}
4321
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004322/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4323/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004324static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004325 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004326 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004327
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004328 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4329 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004330 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004331 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004332 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4333 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4334 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004335 }
4336}
4337
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004338/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4339/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004340/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4341/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004342QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4343 QualType Domain) const {
4344 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4345 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4346 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004347 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004348 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4349 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4350 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4351 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004352 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004353
4354 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4355 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004356 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004357 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4358 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4359 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004360 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004361 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004362}
4363
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004364/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4365/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4366/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004367/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004368int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004369 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4370 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004371
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004372 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004373 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004374 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004375 return 1;
4376 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004377}
4378
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004379/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4380/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4381/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004382unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004383 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004384
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004385 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004386 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004387 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004388 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004389 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4390 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4391 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4392 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004393 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004394 case BuiltinType::Short:
4395 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004396 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004397 case BuiltinType::Int:
4398 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004399 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004400 case BuiltinType::Long:
4401 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004402 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004403 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4404 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004405 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004406 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4407 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4408 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004409 }
4410}
4411
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004412/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4413/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4414///
4415/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4416/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004417QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004418 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4419 return QualType();
4420
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004421 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004422 if (!Field)
4423 return QualType();
4424
4425 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4426
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004427 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004428 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4429 // GCC extension compatibility: if the bit-field size is less than or equal
4430 // to the size of int, it gets promoted no matter what its type is.
4431 // For instance, unsigned long bf : 4 gets promoted to signed int.
4432 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4433 return IntTy;
4434
4435 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4436 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4437
4438 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4439 // like the base type.
4440 // FIXME: This doesn't quite match what gcc does, but what gcc does here
4441 // is ridiculous.
4442 return QualType();
4443}
4444
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004445/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4446/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4447/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004448QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004449 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4450 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004451 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4452 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004453
4454 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4455 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4456 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4457 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4458 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4459 // unsigned long long int [...]
4460 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4461 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4462 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4463 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4464 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4465 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4466 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4467 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4468 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4469 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4470 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4471 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4472 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4473 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4474 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4475 }
4476 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4477 }
4478 }
4479
4480 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004481 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4482 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004483 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4484 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004485 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4486 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4487}
4488
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004489/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4490/// type and returns its ownership.
4491Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4492 while (!T.isNull()) {
4493 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4494 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4495 if (T->isArrayType())
4496 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4497 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4498 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4499 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004500 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004501 else
4502 break;
4503 }
4504
4505 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4506}
4507
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004508static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4509 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4510 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4511 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4512 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004513 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004514}
4515
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004516/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004517/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004518/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004519int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004520 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4521 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004522
4523 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4524 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4525 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4526 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4527 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4528
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004529 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004530
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004531 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4532 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004533
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004534 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4535 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004536
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004537 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4538 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4539 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4540 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004541
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004542 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4543 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4544 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4545 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4546 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004547
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004548 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4549 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004550 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004551 return -1;
4552 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004553
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004554 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4555 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4556 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004557
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004558 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4559 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004560 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004561 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004562}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004563
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004564// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004565QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004566 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004567 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004568 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004569
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004570 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004571
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004572 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004573 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004574 // int flags;
4575 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004576 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004577 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004578 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004579 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4580
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004581 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004582 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004583 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004584 SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004585 SourceLocation(), nullptr,
4586 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4587 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004588 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004589 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004590 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004591 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004592 }
4593
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004594 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004595 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004596
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004597 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004598}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004599
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004600QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4601 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004602 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004603 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4604 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4605 }
4606 return ObjCSuperType;
4607}
4608
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004609void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004610 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004611 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4612 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4613}
4614
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004615QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004616 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4617 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4618
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004619 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004620 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004621 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4622 RD->startDefinition();
4623
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004624 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4625 UnsignedLongTy,
4626 UnsignedLongTy,
4627 };
4628
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004629 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004630 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004631 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004632 };
4633
4634 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004635 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4636 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004637 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4638 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004639 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004640 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004641 }
4642
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004643 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004644
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004645 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004646
4647 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4648}
4649
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004650QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004651 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4652 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4653
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004654 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004655 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004656 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4657 RD->startDefinition();
4658
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004659 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4660 UnsignedLongTy,
4661 UnsignedLongTy,
4662 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4663 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4664 };
4665
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004666 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004667 "reserved",
4668 "Size",
4669 "CopyFuncPtr",
4670 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4671 };
4672
4673 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004674 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4675 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004676 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4677 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004678 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004679 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004680 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004681 }
4682
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004683 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004684
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004685 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004686 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4687}
4688
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004689/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4690/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4691/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4692bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4693 const VarDecl *D) {
4694 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4695 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4696 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4697
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004698 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004699 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004700
4701 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4702
4703 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4704
4705 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4706 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4707 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4708
4709 switch (lifetime) {
4710 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4711
4712 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4713 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4714 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4715 return false;
4716
4717 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4718 // byref routines.
4719 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4720 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4721 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4722 return true;
4723 }
4724 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4725 }
4726 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4727 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004728}
4729
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004730bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4731 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4732 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4733
4734 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4735 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4736 return false;
4737
4738 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00004739 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004740 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4741 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4742 }
4743 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4744 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4745 // MRR.
4746 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4747 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4748 else
4749 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4750 return true;
4751}
4752
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004753TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4754 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00004755 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
4756 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004757 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4758}
4759
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004760// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4761// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00004762static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004763 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00004764 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4765 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004766
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00004767 return false;
4768}
4769
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004770/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004771/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004772CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004773 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4774 return CharUnits::Zero();
4775
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004776 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004777
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004778 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004779 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004780 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004781 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4782 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004783 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004784 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004785}
4786
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00004787bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
4788 return getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
4789 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
4790 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
4791}
4792
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004793static inline
4794std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4795 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004796}
4797
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004798/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004799/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004800std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4801 std::string S;
4802
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004803 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4804 QualType BlockTy =
4805 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4806 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004807 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004808 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
4809 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
4810 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004811 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004812 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004813 // Compute size of all parameters.
4814 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4815 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4816 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004817 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4818 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004819 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4820 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004821 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00004822 if (sz.isZero())
4823 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004824 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004825 ParmOffset += sz;
4826 }
4827 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004828 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004829 // Block pointer and offset.
4830 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004831
4832 // Argument types.
4833 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004834 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004835 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4836 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4837 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4838 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4839 // elements.
4840 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4841 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4842 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4843 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004844 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004845 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
4846 S, true /*Extended*/);
4847 else
4848 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004849 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004850 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004851 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004852
4853 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004854}
4855
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004856bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004857 std::string& S) {
4858 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004859 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004860 CharUnits ParmOffset;
4861 // Compute size of all parameters.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004862 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4863 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004864 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004865 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004866 continue;
4867
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004868 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004869 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004870 ParmOffset += sz;
4871 }
4872 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4873 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
4874
4875 // Argument types.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004876 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004877 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4878 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4879 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4880 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4881 // elements.
4882 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4883 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4884 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4885 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4886 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
4887 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4888 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4889 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004890
4891 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004892}
4893
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004894/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
4895/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
4896/// block object types.
4897void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
4898 QualType T, std::string& S,
4899 bool Extended) const {
4900 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
4901 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
4902 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004903 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004904 true /*OutermostType*/,
4905 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
4906 false /*StructField*/,
4907 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
4908 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
4909}
4910
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004911/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004912/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004913bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004914 std::string& S,
4915 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004916 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004917 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004918 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4919 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004920 // Compute size of all parameters.
4921 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4922 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4923 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004924 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004925 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
4926 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004927 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004928 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004929 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00004930 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004931 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004932 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004933 continue;
4934
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004935 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
4936 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004937 ParmOffset += sz;
4938 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004939 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004940 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004941 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004942
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004943 // Argument types.
4944 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004945 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004946 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004947 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004948 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00004949 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004950 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4951 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4952 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00004953 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004954 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4955 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4956 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004957 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4958 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004959 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004960 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004961 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004962
4963 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004964}
4965
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004966ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
4967ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
4968 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
4969 const Decl *Container) const {
4970 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004971 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004972 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
4973 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00004974 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
4975 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
4976 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004977 } else {
4978 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
4979 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
4980 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
4981 return PID;
4982 }
4983 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004984}
4985
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004986/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004987/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004988/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
4989/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004990/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
4991/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
4992/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
4993/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
4994/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004995/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
4996/// @code
4997/// enum PropertyAttributes {
4998/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
4999/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5000/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5001/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
5002/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
5003/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
5004/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00005005/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005006/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5007/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5008/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5009/// };
5010/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005011void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005012 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005013 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005014 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5015 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005016 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005017
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005018 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5019 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5020 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5021 Dynamic = true;
5022 else
5023 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005024 }
5025
5026 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5027 S = "T";
5028
5029 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005030 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5031 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005032 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005033
5034 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5035 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005036 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5037 S += ",C";
5038 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5039 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005040 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5041 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005042 } else {
5043 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5044 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5045 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005046 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005047 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005048 }
5049 }
5050
5051 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5052 // are "dynamic by default".
5053 if (Dynamic)
5054 S += ",D";
5055
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005056 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5057 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005058
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005059 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5060 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005061 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005062 }
5063
5064 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5065 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005066 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005067 }
5068
5069 if (SynthesizePID) {
5070 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5071 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005072 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005073 }
5074
5075 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5076}
5077
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005078/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005079/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5080/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005081/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5082///
5083void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005084 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005085 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005086 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005087 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005088 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005089 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005090 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5091 }
5092 }
5093}
5094
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005095void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005096 const FieldDecl *Field) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005097 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5098 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5099 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5100 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005101 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahaniandaef00b2008-12-22 23:22:27 +00005102 true /* outermost type */);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005103}
5104
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005105void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5106 std::string& S) const {
5107 // Encode result type.
5108 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5109 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5110 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5111 true /* outermost type */,
5112 true /* encoding property */);
5113}
5114
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005115static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5116 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5117 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005118 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5119 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5120 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5121 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005122 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005123 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005124 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005125 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5126 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005127 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005128 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5129 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5130 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5131 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5132 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005133 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5134 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005135 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5136 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005137 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005138 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5139 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5140 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5141 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005142 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005143 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5144
5145 case BuiltinType::Half:
5146 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5147 return ' ';
5148
5149 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5150 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5151 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5152 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5153
5154 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5155 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5156 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5157 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5158 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5159 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5160 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005161 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005162 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005163 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5164#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5165#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5166 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5167#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5168 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005169 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005170 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005171}
5172
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005173static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5174 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5175
5176 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5177 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5178 return 'i';
5179
5180 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005181 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5182 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005183}
5184
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005185static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005186 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005187 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005188 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005189 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5190 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5191 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5192 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5193 //
5194 // struct
5195 // {
5196 // int integer;
5197 // int flags:2;
5198 // };
5199 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5200 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5201 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5202 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5203 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005204 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005205 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5206 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005207 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005208 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5209 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005210 else {
5211 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5212 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5213 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005214 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005215 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005216}
5217
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005218// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005219void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5220 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5221 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005222 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005223 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005224 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005225 bool StructField,
5226 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005227 bool EncodeClassNames,
5228 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005229 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5230 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5231 case Type::Builtin:
5232 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005233 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005234 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005235 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5236 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5237 else
5238 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005239 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005240
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005241 case Type::Complex: {
5242 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005243 S += 'j';
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005244 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr,
5245 false, false);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005246 return;
5247 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005248
5249 case Type::Atomic: {
5250 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5251 S += 'A';
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005252 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr,
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005253 false, false);
5254 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005255 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005256
5257 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5258 case Type::Pointer:
5259 case Type::LValueReference:
5260 case Type::RValueReference: {
5261 QualType PointeeTy;
5262 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5263 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5264 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5265 S += ':';
5266 return;
5267 }
5268 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5269 } else {
5270 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5271 }
5272
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005273 bool isReadOnly = false;
5274 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5275 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5276 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005277 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005278 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005279 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5280 isReadOnly = true;
5281 S += 'r';
5282 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005283 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005284 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005285 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5286 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005287 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5288 isReadOnly = true;
5289 S += 'r';
5290 }
5291 }
5292 if (isReadOnly) {
5293 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5294 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5295 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005296 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005297 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005298 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005299
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005300 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5301 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5302 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005303 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005304 S += '*';
5305 return;
5306 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005307 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005308 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5309 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5310 S += '#';
5311 return;
5312 }
5313 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5314 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5315 S += '@';
5316 return;
5317 }
5318 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005319 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005320 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005321 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5322
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005323 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005324 nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005325 return;
5326 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005327
5328 case Type::ConstantArray:
5329 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5330 case Type::VariableArray: {
5331 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5332
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005333 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005334 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5335 S += '^';
5336
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005337 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005338 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5339 } else {
5340 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005341
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005342 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5343 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5344 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005345 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005346 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5347 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005348 S += '0';
5349 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005350
5351 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005352 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5353 S += ']';
5354 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005355 return;
5356 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005357
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005358 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5359 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005360 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005361 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005362
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005363 case Type::Record: {
5364 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005365 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005366 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5367 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5368 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005369 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5370 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5371 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005372 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5373 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005374 TemplateArgs.data(),
5375 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005376 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005377 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005378 } else {
5379 S += '?';
5380 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005381 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005382 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005383 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5384 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD);
5385 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005386 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005387 if (FD) {
5388 S += '"';
5389 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5390 S += '"';
5391 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005392
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005393 // Special case bit-fields.
5394 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5395 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005396 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005397 } else {
5398 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5399 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5400 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5401 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5402 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5403 /*StructField*/true);
5404 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005405 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005406 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005407 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005408 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005409 return;
5410 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005411
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005412 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5413 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005414 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005415 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005416 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005417
5418 S += '<';
5419 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005420 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5421 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5422 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5423 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005424 // Block self
5425 S += "@?";
5426 // Block parameters
5427 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00005428 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5429 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5430 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5431 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5432 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005433 }
5434 S += '>';
5435 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005436 return;
5437 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005438
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00005439 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5440 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5441 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5442 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5443 S += "{objc_object=}";
5444 return;
5445 }
5446 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5447 S += "{objc_class=}";
5448 return;
5449 }
5450 }
5451
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005452 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5453 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5454 T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005455
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005456 // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5457 // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5458 const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005459 // @encode(class_name)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005460 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005461 S += '{';
5462 const IdentifierInfo *II = OI->getIdentifier();
5463 S += II->getName();
5464 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005465 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005466 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5467 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005468 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005469 if (Field->isBitField())
5470 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005471 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005472 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5473 false, false, false, false, false,
5474 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005475 }
5476 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005477 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005478 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005479
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005480 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5481 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005482 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5483 S += '@';
5484 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005485 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005486
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005487 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5488 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5489 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5490 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005491 S += '#';
5492 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005493 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005494
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005495 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005496 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005497 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5498 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005499 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005500 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5501 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005502 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005503 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005504 S += '<';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005505 S += I->getNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005506 S += '>';
5507 }
5508 S += '"';
5509 }
5510 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005511 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005512
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005513 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5514 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005515 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5516 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005517 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005518 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005519 // {...};
5520 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005521 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005522 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005523 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5524 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5525 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5526 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5527 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5528 S += '{';
5529 S += OI->getIdentifier()->getName();
5530 S += '}';
5531 return;
5532 }
5533 }
5534 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005535 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5536 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005537 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005538 false, false, false, false, false,
5539 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005540 return;
5541 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005542
5543 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005544 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5545 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005546 S += '"';
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005547 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getIdentifier()->getName();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005548 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005549 S += '<';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005550 S += I->getNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005551 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005552 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005553 S += '"';
5554 }
5555 return;
5556 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005557
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005558 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005559 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5560 case Type::MemberPointer:
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005561 return;
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005562
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005563 case Type::Vector:
5564 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005565 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is
5566 // insufficient.
5567 // FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5568 return;
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005569
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005570 case Type::Auto:
5571 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5572 // Just ignore it.
5573 return;
5574
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005575#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5576#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5577#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5578 case Type::KIND:
5579#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5580 case Type::KIND:
5581#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5582 case Type::KIND:
5583#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5584 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005585 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005586 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005587}
5588
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005589void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5590 std::string &S,
5591 const FieldDecl *FD,
5592 bool includeVBases) const {
5593 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5594 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5595 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5596 return;
5597
5598 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5599 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5600 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5601
5602 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00005603 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5604 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5605 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005606 if (base->isEmpty())
5607 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005608 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005609 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5610 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5611 }
5612 }
5613 }
5614
5615 unsigned i = 0;
5616 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5617 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5618 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field, ++i) {
5619 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5620 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005621 std::make_pair(offs, *Field));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005622 }
5623
5624 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00005625 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5626 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005627 if (base->isEmpty())
5628 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005629 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00005630 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5631 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005632 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5633 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005634 }
5635 }
5636
5637 CharUnits size;
5638 if (CXXRec) {
5639 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5640 } else {
5641 size = layout.getSize();
5642 }
5643
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005644#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005645 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005646#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005647 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5648 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5649
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005650 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5651 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005652 if (FD) {
5653 S += "\"_vptr$";
5654 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5655 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5656 S += recname;
5657 S += '"';
5658 }
5659 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005660#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005661 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005662#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005663 }
5664
5665 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5666 // Mark the end of the structure.
5667 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5668 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005669 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005670 }
5671
5672 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005673#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005674 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005675 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5676 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5677 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5678 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5679 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5680 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5681 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5682 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5683 // longer then though.
5684 CurOffs += padding;
5685 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005686#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005687
5688 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005689 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005690 break; // reached end of structure.
5691
5692 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5693 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5694 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5695 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5696 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5697 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005698 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005699#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005700 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005701#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005702 } else {
5703 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5704 if (FD) {
5705 S += '"';
5706 S += field->getNameAsString();
5707 S += '"';
5708 }
5709
5710 if (field->isBitField()) {
5711 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005712#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005713 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005714#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005715 } else {
5716 QualType qt = field->getType();
5717 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5718 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5719 /*OutermostType*/false,
5720 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5721 /*StructField*/true);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005722#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005723 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005724#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005725 }
5726 }
5727 }
5728}
5729
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005730void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00005731 std::string& S) const {
5732 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5733 S += 'n';
5734 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5735 S += 'N';
5736 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5737 S += 'o';
5738 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5739 S += 'O';
5740 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5741 S += 'R';
5742 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5743 S += 'V';
5744}
5745
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005746TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5747 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005748 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005749 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005750 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005751 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005752 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00005753}
5754
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005755TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5756 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005757 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5758 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005759 }
5760 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00005761}
5762
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005763TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5764 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005765 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005766 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005767 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005768 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005769 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00005770}
5771
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005772ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5773 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5774 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5775 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5776 SourceLocation(),
5777 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005778 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005779 SourceLocation(), true);
5780 }
5781
5782 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5783}
5784
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005785//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5786// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5787//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5788
5789static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5790 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005791 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5792 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005793}
5794
5795static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5796 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005797 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5798 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005799}
5800
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005801static TypedefDecl *
5802CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005803 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005804 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005805 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5806 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5807 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5808 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5809 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005810 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005811 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005812 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005813 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005814 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005815 }
5816
5817 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5818
5819 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5820 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5821 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5822
5823 // void *__stack;
5824 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5825 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
5826
5827 // void *__gr_top;
5828 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5829 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
5830
5831 // void *__vr_top;
5832 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5833 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
5834
5835 // int __gr_offs;
5836 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
5837 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
5838
5839 // int __vr_offs;
5840 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
5841 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
5842
5843 // Create fields
5844 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5845 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5846 VaListTagDecl,
5847 SourceLocation(),
5848 SourceLocation(),
5849 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005850 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5851 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005852 /*Mutable=*/false,
5853 ICIS_NoInit);
5854 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5855 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5856 }
5857 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5858 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
5859 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
5860
5861 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005862 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005863}
5864
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005865static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5866 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5867 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5868
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005869 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005870 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5871
5872 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5873 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5874 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5875
5876 // unsigned char gpr;
5877 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5878 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
5879
5880 // unsigned char fpr;
5881 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5882 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
5883
5884 // unsigned short reserved;
5885 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
5886 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
5887
5888 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5889 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5890 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
5891
5892 // void* reg_save_area;
5893 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5894 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
5895
5896 // Create fields
5897 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5898 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
5899 SourceLocation(),
5900 SourceLocation(),
5901 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005902 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5903 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005904 /*Mutable=*/false,
5905 ICIS_NoInit);
5906 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5907 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5908 }
5909 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5910 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005911 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005912
5913 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005914 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
5915 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
5916
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005917 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5918 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5919
5920 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5921 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5922 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5923 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5924 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005925 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005926}
5927
5928static TypedefDecl *
5929CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5930 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5931 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005932 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005933 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5934
5935 const size_t NumFields = 4;
5936 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5937 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5938
5939 // unsigned gp_offset;
5940 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5941 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
5942
5943 // unsigned fp_offset;
5944 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5945 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
5946
5947 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5948 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5949 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
5950
5951 // void* reg_save_area;
5952 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5953 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
5954
5955 // Create fields
5956 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5957 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5958 VaListTagDecl,
5959 SourceLocation(),
5960 SourceLocation(),
5961 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005962 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5963 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005964 /*Mutable=*/false,
5965 ICIS_NoInit);
5966 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5967 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5968 }
5969 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5970 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005971 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005972
5973 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005974 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
5975 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
5976
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005977 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5978 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5979
5980 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5981 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5982 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5983 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5984 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005985 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005986}
5987
5988static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5989 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
5990 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
5991 QualType IntArrayType
5992 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
5993 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005994 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005995}
5996
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005997static TypedefDecl *
5998CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005999 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006000 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006001 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6002 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6003 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6004 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6005 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6006 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6007 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006008 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006009 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006010 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006011 }
6012
6013 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6014
6015 // void * __ap;
6016 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6017 VaListDecl,
6018 SourceLocation(),
6019 SourceLocation(),
6020 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6021 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006022 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6023 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006024 /*Mutable=*/false,
6025 ICIS_NoInit);
6026 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6027 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6028
6029 // };
6030 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6031
6032 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006033 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6034 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006035}
6036
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006037static TypedefDecl *
6038CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6039 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6040 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006041 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006042 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6043
6044 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6045 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6046 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6047
6048 // long __gpr;
6049 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6050 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6051
6052 // long __fpr;
6053 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6054 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6055
6056 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6057 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6058 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6059
6060 // void *__reg_save_area;
6061 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6062 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6063
6064 // Create fields
6065 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6066 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6067 VaListTagDecl,
6068 SourceLocation(),
6069 SourceLocation(),
6070 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006071 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6072 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006073 /*Mutable=*/false,
6074 ICIS_NoInit);
6075 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6076 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6077 }
6078 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6079 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6080 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6081
6082 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006083 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6084 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006085 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6086 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6087
6088 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6089 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6090 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6091 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6092 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006093
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006094 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006095}
6096
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006097static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6098 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6099 switch (Kind) {
6100 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6101 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6102 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6103 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006104 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6105 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006106 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6107 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6108 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6109 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6110 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6111 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006112 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6113 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006114 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6115 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006116 }
6117
6118 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6119}
6120
6121TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006122 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006123 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006124 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6125 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006126
6127 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6128}
6129
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006130QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6131 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6132 // declaration.
6133 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6134 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6135
6136 return VaListTagTy;
6137}
6138
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006139void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006140 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006141 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006142
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006143 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006144}
6145
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006146/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6147/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006148TemplateName
6149ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6150 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006151 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6152 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6153
6154 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6155 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6156 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6157
6158 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006159 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006160 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6161 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6162 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6163 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6164 *Storage++ = D;
6165 }
6166
6167 return TemplateName(OT);
6168}
6169
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006170/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6171/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006172TemplateName
6173ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6174 bool TemplateKeyword,
6175 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006176 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6177
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006178 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006179 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6180 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6181
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006182 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006183 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6184 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6185 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006186 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6187 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006188 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6189 }
6190
6191 return TemplateName(QTN);
6192}
6193
6194/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6195/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006196TemplateName
6197ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6198 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006199 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006200 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006201
6202 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6203 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6204
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006205 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006206 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6207 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6208
6209 if (QTN)
6210 return TemplateName(QTN);
6211
6212 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6213 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006214 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6215 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006216 } else {
6217 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006218 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6219 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006220 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6221 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6222 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6223 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006224 }
6225
6226 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6227 return TemplateName(QTN);
6228}
6229
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006230/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6231/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6232TemplateName
6233ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006234 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006235 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6236 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6237
6238 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6239 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006240
6241 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006242 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6243 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006244
6245 if (QTN)
6246 return TemplateName(QTN);
6247
6248 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6249 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006250 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6251 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006252 } else {
6253 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006254 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6255 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006256
6257 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6258 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6259 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6260 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006261 }
6262
6263 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6264 return TemplateName(QTN);
6265}
6266
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006267TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006268ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6269 TemplateName replacement) const {
6270 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6271 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006272
6273 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006274 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6275 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6276
6277 if (!subst) {
6278 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6279 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6280 }
6281
6282 return TemplateName(subst);
6283}
6284
6285TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006286ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6287 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6288 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6289 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6290 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006291
6292 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006293 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6294 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6295
6296 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006297 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006298 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6299 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6300 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6301 }
6302
6303 return TemplateName(Subst);
6304}
6305
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006306/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006307/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6308/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006309CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006310 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006311 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006312 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6313 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006314 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6315 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6316 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6317 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6318 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6319 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6320 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6321 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6322 }
6323
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006324 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006325}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006326
6327//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6328// Type Predicates.
6329//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6330
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006331/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6332/// garbage collection attribute.
6333///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006334Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006335 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006336 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6337
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006338 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006339 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6340
6341 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6342 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6343 // as __strong.
6344 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6345 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6346 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6347 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6348 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6349 } else {
6350 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6351 // pointer.
6352#ifndef NDEBUG
6353 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6354 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6355 CT = AT->getElementType();
6356 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6357#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006358 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006359 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006360}
6361
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006362//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6363// Type Compatibility Testing
6364//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006365
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006366/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006367/// compatible.
6368static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6369 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006370 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006371 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006372 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006373}
6374
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006375bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6376 QualType SecondVec) {
6377 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6378 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6379
6380 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6381 return true;
6382
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006383 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6384 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006385 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6386 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006387 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006388 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006389 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6390 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6391 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6392 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006393 return true;
6394
6395 return false;
6396}
6397
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006398//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6399// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6400//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6401
6402/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6403/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006404bool
6405ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6406 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006407 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006408 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00006409 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6410 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006411 return true;
6412 return false;
6413}
6414
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006415/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6416/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006417bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6418 QualType rhs) {
6419 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6420 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6421 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6422
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006423 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006424 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006425 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006426 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6427 match = true;
6428 break;
6429 }
6430 }
6431 if (!match)
6432 return false;
6433 }
6434 return true;
6435}
6436
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006437/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6438/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6439bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6440 bool compare) {
6441 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006442 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006443 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6444 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006445 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006446 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6447 return true;
6448
6449 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006450 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006451
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006452 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006453
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006454 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006455 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006456 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6457 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006458 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006459 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6460 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6461 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006462 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006463 return false;
6464 }
6465 }
6466 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6467 return true;
6468 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006469 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006470 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006471 bool match = false;
6472
6473 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6474 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6475 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006476 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006477 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6478 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6479 match = true;
6480 break;
6481 }
6482 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006483 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006484 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6485 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006486 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006487 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6488 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6489 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006490 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006491 match = true;
6492 break;
6493 }
6494 }
6495 }
6496 if (!match)
6497 return false;
6498 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006499
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006500 return true;
6501 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006502
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006503 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6504 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6505
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006506 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006507 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006508 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006509 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006510 bool match = false;
6511
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006512 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006513 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6514 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006515 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6516 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006517 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006518 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6519 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6520 match = true;
6521 break;
6522 }
6523 }
6524 if (!match)
6525 return false;
6526 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006527
6528 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6529 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6530 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6531 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6532 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6533 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6534 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6535 // assume that it is mismatch.
6536 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6537 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006538 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006539 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006540 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006541 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6542 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6543 match = true;
6544 break;
6545 }
6546 }
6547 if (!match)
6548 return false;
6549 }
6550 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006551 return true;
6552 }
6553 return false;
6554}
6555
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006556/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006557/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6558/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6559///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006560bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6561 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006562 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6563 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6564
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006565 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006566 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6567 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006568 return true;
6569
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006570 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006571 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6572 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006573 false);
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006574
6575 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6576 return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6577 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6578
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006579 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6580 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006581 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006582
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006583 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006584}
6585
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006586/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006587/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006588/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6589/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6590/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6591bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6592 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006593 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6594 bool BlockReturnType) {
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006595 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006596 return true;
6597
6598 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6599 return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6600 }
6601
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006602 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006603 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6604 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6605 false);
6606
6607 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6608 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6609 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6610 if (LHS != RHS) {
6611 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006612 return BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006613 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006614 return !BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006615 }
6616 else
6617 return true;
6618 }
6619 return false;
6620}
6621
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006622/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6623/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6624/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6625/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6626static
6627void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6628 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6629 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006630 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006631
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006632 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6633 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6634 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6635 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006636
6637 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6638 unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6639 if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6640 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6641 else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006642 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006643 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6644 LHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006645 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6646 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6647 }
6648
6649 unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6650 if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
Dan Gohman145f3f12010-04-19 16:39:44 +00006651 ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6652 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006653 for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6654 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6655 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00006656 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006657 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006658 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6659 RHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006660 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6661 RHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6662 E = RHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I)
6663 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count((*I)))
6664 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back((*I));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006665 }
6666}
6667
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006668/// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6669/// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6670/// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6671/// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6672QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006673 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6674 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6675 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6676 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6677 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6678 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregor0b144e12011-12-15 00:29:59 +00006679 if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006680 return QualType();
6681
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006682 do {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006683 LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006684 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006685 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006686 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6687
6688 QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6689 if (!Protocols.empty())
6690 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6691 Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6692 return Result;
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006693 }
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006694 } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006695
6696 return QualType();
6697}
6698
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006699bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6700 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6701 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6702 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6703
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006704 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6705 // the LHS.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006706 if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006707 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006708
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006709 // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS. If the LHS is not
6710 // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
Steve Naroffc277ad12009-07-18 15:33:26 +00006711 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006712 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006713
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006714 // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. If the RHS doesn't,
6715 // more detailed analysis is required.
6716 if (RHS->getNumProtocols() == 0) {
6717 // OK, if LHS is a superclass of RHS *and*
6718 // this superclass is assignment compatible with LHS.
6719 // false otherwise.
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006720 bool IsSuperClass =
6721 LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6722 if (IsSuperClass) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006723 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6724 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6725 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6726 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6727 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006728 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006729 // If super class has no protocols, it is not a match.
6730 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
6731 return false;
6732
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006733 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
6734 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6735 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006736 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6737 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6738 break;
6739 }
6740 }
6741 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6742 return false;
6743 }
6744 return true;
6745 }
6746 return false;
6747 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006748
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006749 for (const auto *LHSPI : LHS->quals()) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006750 bool RHSImplementsProtocol = false;
6751
6752 // If the RHS doesn't implement the protocol on the left, the types
6753 // are incompatible.
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006754 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals()) {
6755 if (RHSPI->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSPI->getIdentifier())) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006756 RHSImplementsProtocol = true;
Steve Narofffac5bc92009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006757 break;
6758 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006759 }
6760 // FIXME: For better diagnostics, consider passing back the protocol name.
6761 if (!RHSImplementsProtocol)
6762 return false;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006763 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006764 // The RHS implements all protocols listed on the LHS.
6765 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006766}
6767
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006768bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6769 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006770 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6771 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006772
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006773 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006774 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006775
6776 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6777 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006778}
6779
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00006780bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6781 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6782 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6783 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6784}
6785
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006786/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006787/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006788/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006789/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006790bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6791 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006792 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00006793 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6794
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006795 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006796}
6797
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006798bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00006799 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006800}
6801
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006802bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6803 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6804}
6805
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006806/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6807/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6808/// QualType()
6809QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6810 bool OfBlockPointer,
6811 bool Unqualified) {
6812 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6813 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6814 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006815 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
6816 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006817 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6818 if (!MT.isNull())
6819 return MT;
6820 }
6821 }
6822 }
6823
6824 return QualType();
6825}
6826
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006827/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6828/// parameter types
6829QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6830 bool OfBlockPointer,
6831 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006832 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6833 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6834 // type is compatible with a union member
6835 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6836 Unqualified);
6837 if (!lmerge.isNull())
6838 return lmerge;
6839
6840 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6841 Unqualified);
6842 if (!rmerge.isNull())
6843 return rmerge;
6844
6845 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6846}
6847
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006848QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006849 bool OfBlockPointer,
6850 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006851 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6852 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006853 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
6854 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006855 bool allLTypes = true;
6856 bool allRTypes = true;
6857
6858 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006859 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006860 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006861 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
6862 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006863 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
6864 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
6865 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006866 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006867 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006868 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006869 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006870 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006871 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006872
6873 if (Unqualified)
6874 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
6875
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006876 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
6877 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006878 if (Unqualified) {
6879 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6880 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6881 }
6882
6883 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006884 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006885 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006886 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006887
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00006888 // FIXME: double check this
6889 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6890 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6891 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006892 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
6893 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006894
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006895 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00006896 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006897 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006898
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006899 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00006900 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
6901 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006902 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
6903 return QualType();
6904
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006905 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
6906 return QualType();
6907
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006908 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
6909 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006910
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00006911 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6912 allLTypes = false;
6913 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6914 allRTypes = false;
6915
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006916 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006917
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006918 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006919 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
6920 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006921 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
6922 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006923 return QualType();
6924
6925 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
6926 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
6927 return QualType();
6928
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00006929 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
6930 return QualType();
6931
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006932 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6933 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
6934 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006935
6936 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006937 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006938 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
6939 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6940 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6941 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
6942 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6943 if (paramType.isNull())
6944 return QualType();
6945
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006946 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006947 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
6948
6949 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006950 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006951 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
6952 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006953 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006954
6955 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006956 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006957 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006958 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006959 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006960
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006961 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6962 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006963
6964 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
6965 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00006966 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006967 }
6968
6969 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
6970 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
6971
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006972 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006973 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006974 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006975 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
6976 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
6977 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
6978 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
6979 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
6980 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006981 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
6982 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006983
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00006984 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00006985 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006986 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
6987 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6988 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00006989 return QualType();
6990 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006991
6992 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
6993 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006994 return QualType();
6995 }
6996
6997 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6998 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006999
7000 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7001 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007002 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007003 }
7004
7005 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7006 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007007 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007008}
7009
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007010/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7011static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7012 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7013 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7014 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7015 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7016 // type.
7017 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7018 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7019 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7020 return other;
7021
7022 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7023 // integral type of the same size.
7024 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7025 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7026 return other;
7027
7028 return QualType();
7029}
7030
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007031QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007032 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007033 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007034 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7035 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7036 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007037 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7038 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007039 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7040 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007041
7042 if (Unqualified) {
7043 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7044 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7045 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007046
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007047 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7048 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7049
7050 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7051 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7052 return LHS;
7053
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007054 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007055 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7056 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007057 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7058 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7059 // mismatch.
7060 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007061 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7062 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007063 return QualType();
7064
7065 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7066 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7067 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7068 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7069 // qualified __strong.
7070 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7071 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7072 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7073
7074 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7075 return QualType();
7076
7077 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7078 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7079 }
7080 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7081 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7082 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007083 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007084 }
7085
7086 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007087
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007088 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7089 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007090
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007091 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7092 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7093 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7094 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007095
7096 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007097 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7098 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7099 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7100 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007101
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007102 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7103 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7104 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7105
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007106 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7107 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7108 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007109
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007110 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007111 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007112 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7113 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007114 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007115 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007116 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007117 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007118 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007119 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007120 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007121 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7122 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7123 return LHS;
7124 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7125 return RHS;
7126 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007127
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007128 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007129 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007130
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007131 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007132 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007133#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7134#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007135#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007136#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7137#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7138#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007139 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007140
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007141 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007142 case Type::LValueReference:
7143 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007144 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007145 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007146
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007147 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007148 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7149 case Type::VariableArray:
7150 case Type::FunctionProto:
7151 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007152 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007153
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007154 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007155 {
7156 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007157 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7158 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007159 if (Unqualified) {
7160 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7161 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7162 }
7163 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7164 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007165 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007166 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007167 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007168 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007169 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007170 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7171 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007172 case Type::BlockPointer:
7173 {
7174 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007175 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7176 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007177 if (Unqualified) {
7178 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7179 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7180 }
7181 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7182 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007183 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7184 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7185 return LHS;
7186 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7187 return RHS;
7188 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7189 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007190 case Type::Atomic:
7191 {
7192 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7193 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7194 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7195 if (Unqualified) {
7196 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7197 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7198 }
7199 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7200 Unqualified);
7201 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7202 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7203 return LHS;
7204 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7205 return RHS;
7206 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7207 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007208 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007209 {
7210 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7211 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7212 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7213 return QualType();
7214
7215 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7216 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007217 if (Unqualified) {
7218 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7219 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7220 }
7221
7222 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007223 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007224 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7225 return LHS;
7226 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7227 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007228 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7229 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7230 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7231 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007232 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7233 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007234 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7235 return LHS;
7236 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7237 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007238 if (LVAT) {
7239 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7240 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7241 // has to be different.
7242 return LHS;
7243 }
7244 if (RVAT) {
7245 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7246 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7247 // has to be different.
7248 return RHS;
7249 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007250 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7251 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007252 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7253 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007254 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007255 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007256 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007257 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007258 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007259 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007260 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007261 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007262 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007263 case Type::Complex:
7264 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7265 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007266 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007267 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007268 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7269 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007270 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007271 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007272 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7273 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007274 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7275 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007276 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7277 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7278 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007279 return LHS;
7280
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007281 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007282 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007283 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007284 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7285 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7286 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007287 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7288 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007289 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007290 return QualType();
7291 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007292 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7293 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007294 return LHS;
7295
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007296 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007297 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007298 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007299
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007300 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007301}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007302
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007303bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7304 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7305 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007306 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7307 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007308 return false;
7309 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7310 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7311 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7312 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00007313 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007314 for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7315 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007316 return false;
7317 }
7318 return true;
7319}
7320
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007321/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7322/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7323/// return types.
7324QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7325 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7326 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7327 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7328 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7329 return LHS;
7330 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7331 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7332 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007333 QualType OldReturnType =
7334 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007335 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007336 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007337 QualType ResReturnType =
7338 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7339 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7340 return QualType();
7341 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7342 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7343 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7344 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7345 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007346 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7347 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007348 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007349 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007350 return ResultType;
7351 }
7352 }
7353 return QualType();
7354 }
7355
7356 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7357 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7358 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7359 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7360 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7361 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7362 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7363 return QualType();
7364
7365 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7366 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7367 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7368 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7369 // qualified __strong.
7370 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7371 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7372 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7373
7374 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7375 return QualType();
7376
7377 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7378 return LHS;
7379 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7380 return RHS;
7381 return QualType();
7382 }
7383
7384 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7385 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7386 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7387 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7388 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7389 return LHS;
7390 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7391 return RHS;
7392 }
7393 return QualType();
7394}
7395
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007396//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007397// Integer Predicates
7398//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007399
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007400unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00007401 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007402 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007403 if (T->isBooleanType())
7404 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007405 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007406 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7407}
7408
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007409QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007410 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007411
7412 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7413 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7414 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007415 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007416
7417 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7418 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007419 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007420
7421 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7422 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007423 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7424 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7425 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7426 return UnsignedCharTy;
7427 case BuiltinType::Short:
7428 return UnsignedShortTy;
7429 case BuiltinType::Int:
7430 return UnsignedIntTy;
7431 case BuiltinType::Long:
7432 return UnsignedLongTy;
7433 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7434 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007435 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7436 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007437 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007438 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007439 }
7440}
7441
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007442ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7443
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007444void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7445 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007446
7447//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7448// Builtin Type Computation
7449//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7450
7451/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007452/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7453/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7454/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7455/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007456///
7457/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7458/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007459static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007460 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007461 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007462 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007463 // Modifiers.
7464 int HowLong = 0;
7465 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007466 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007467
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007468 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007469 bool Done = false;
7470 while (!Done) {
7471 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007472 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007473 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007474 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007475 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007476 case 'S':
7477 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7478 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7479 Signed = true;
7480 break;
7481 case 'U':
7482 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7483 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7484 Unsigned = true;
7485 break;
7486 case 'L':
7487 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7488 ++HowLong;
7489 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00007490 case 'W':
7491 // This modifier represents int64 type.
7492 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7493 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7494 default:
7495 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7496 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
7497 HowLong = 1;
7498 break;
7499 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
7500 HowLong = 2;
7501 break;
7502 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007503 }
7504 }
7505
7506 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007507
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007508 // Read the base type.
7509 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007510 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007511 case 'v':
7512 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7513 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7514 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7515 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007516 case 'h':
7517 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7518 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7519 Type = Context.HalfTy;
7520 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007521 case 'f':
7522 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7523 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7524 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7525 break;
7526 case 'd':
7527 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7528 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7529 if (HowLong)
7530 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7531 else
7532 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7533 break;
7534 case 's':
7535 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7536 if (Unsigned)
7537 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7538 else
7539 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7540 break;
7541 case 'i':
7542 if (HowLong == 3)
7543 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7544 else if (HowLong == 2)
7545 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7546 else if (HowLong == 1)
7547 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7548 else
7549 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7550 break;
7551 case 'c':
7552 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7553 if (Signed)
7554 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7555 else if (Unsigned)
7556 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7557 else
7558 Type = Context.CharTy;
7559 break;
7560 case 'b': // boolean
7561 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7562 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7563 break;
7564 case 'z': // size_t.
7565 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7566 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7567 break;
7568 case 'F':
7569 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7570 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00007571 case 'G':
7572 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7573 break;
7574 case 'H':
7575 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7576 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00007577 case 'M':
7578 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7579 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007580 case 'a':
7581 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7582 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7583 break;
7584 case 'A':
7585 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7586 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7587 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7588 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
7589 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7590 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7591 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7592 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7593 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7594 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007595 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007596 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007597 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007598 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007599 break;
7600 case 'V': {
7601 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007602 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7603 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007604 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007605
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007606 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7607 RequiresICE, false);
7608 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007609
7610 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00007611 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007612 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007613 break;
7614 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00007615 case 'E': {
7616 char *End;
7617
7618 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7619 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7620
7621 Str = End;
7622
7623 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7624 false);
7625 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7626 break;
7627 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007628 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007629 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7630 false);
7631 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007632 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7633 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00007634 }
7635 case 'Y' : {
7636 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7637 break;
7638 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007639 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00007640 Type = Context.getFILEType();
7641 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007642 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007643 return QualType();
7644 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007645 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007646 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007647 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007648 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007649 else
7650 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7651
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007652 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007653 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007654 return QualType();
7655 }
7656 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00007657 case 'K':
7658 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7659 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7660
7661 if (Type.isNull()) {
7662 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7663 return QualType();
7664 }
7665 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00007666 case 'p':
7667 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7668 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007669 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007670
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007671 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7672 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007673 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00007674 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007675 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7676 case '*':
7677 case '&': {
7678 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7679 // qualified with an address space.
7680 char *End;
7681 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7682 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7683 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7684 Str = End;
7685 }
7686 if (c == '*')
7687 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7688 else
7689 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7690 break;
7691 }
7692 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7693 case 'C':
7694 Type = Type.withConst();
7695 break;
7696 case 'D':
7697 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7698 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00007699 case 'R':
7700 Type = Type.withRestrict();
7701 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007702 }
7703 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007704
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007705 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007706 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007707
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007708 return Type;
7709}
7710
7711/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007712QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007713 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007714 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007715 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007716
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007717 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007718
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007719 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007720 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007721 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7722 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007723 if (Error != GE_None)
7724 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007725
7726 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7727
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007728 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007729 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007730 if (Error != GE_None)
7731 return QualType();
7732
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007733 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7734 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7735 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7736 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7737
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007738 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
7739 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7740 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007741
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007742 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7743 }
7744
7745 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7746 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7747
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007748 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007749 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7750
7751 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7752
7753 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7754 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7755 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00007756
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007757 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007758 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7759 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007760
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007761 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007762}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00007763
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007764static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
7765 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007766 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007767 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007768
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007769 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7770 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7771 case TSK_Undeclared:
7772 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7773 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7774 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007775
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007776 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007777 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007778
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00007779 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
7780 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7781 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7782 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7783 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7784 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007785 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007786 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7787
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007788 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007789 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007790 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007791 }
7792
7793 if (!FD->isInlined())
7794 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007795
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007796 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
7797 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007798 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007799 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
7800
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007801 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7802 // externally visible.
7803 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7804 return External;
7805
7806 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007807 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007808 }
7809
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007810 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
7811 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
7812 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
7813 if (FD->getMostRecentDecl()->isMSExternInline())
7814 return GVA_StrongODR;
7815
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007816 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007817}
7818
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007819static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
7820 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
7821 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
7822 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
7823 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
7824 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7825 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
7826 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
7827 return GVA_StrongODR;
7828 }
7829 return L;
7830}
7831
7832GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
7833 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
7834 FD);
7835}
7836
7837static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
7838 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007839 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
7840 return GVA_Internal;
7841
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007842 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
7843 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
7844 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
7845 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
7846 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
7847
7848 // Let the static local variable inherit it's linkage from the nearest
7849 // enclosing function.
7850 if (LexicalContext)
7851 StaticLocalLinkage =
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007852 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007853
7854 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
7855 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
7856 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
7857 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
7858 : StaticLocalLinkage;
7859 }
7860
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00007861 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
7862 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
7863 // cause link errors.
7864 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
7865 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
7866
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00007867 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007868 case TSK_Undeclared:
7869 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7870 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007871
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007872 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007873 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007874
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007875 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7876 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7877
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007878 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007879 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007880 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00007881
7882 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007883}
7884
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007885GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
7886 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
7887 VD);
7888}
7889
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00007890bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007891 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
7892 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
7893 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00007894 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
7895 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
7896 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00007897 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7898 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
7899 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
7900 return false;
7901 } else
7902 return false;
7903
7904 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
7905 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007906 return false;
7907
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007908 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
7909 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
7910 return false;
7911
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007912 // Aliases and used decls are required.
7913 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
7914 return true;
7915
7916 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7917 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00007918 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00007919 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007920
7921 // Constructors and destructors are required.
7922 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
7923 return true;
7924
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00007925 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
7926 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
7927 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
7928 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
7929 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
7930 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
7931 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
7932 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
7933 return true;
7934 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007935 }
7936 }
7937
7938 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
7939
7940 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
7941 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
7942 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007943 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
7944 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007945 return false;
7946 return true;
7947 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00007948
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007949 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
7950 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
7951
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00007952 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
7953 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007954 return false;
7955
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007956 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007957 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00007958 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
7959 L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007960 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007961
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007962 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
7963 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
7964 return true;
7965
7966 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
7967 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
7968 return true;
7969
7970 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007971}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007972
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007973CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
7974 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007975 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007976 if (IsCXXMethod)
7977 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007978
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007979 return (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) ? CC_X86StdCall : CC_C;
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007980}
7981
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007982bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00007983 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
7984 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
7985}
7986
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00007987VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
7988 if (!VTContext.get()) {
7989 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
7990 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
7991 else
7992 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
7993 }
7994 return VTContext.get();
7995}
7996
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007997MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007998 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00007999 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008000 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8001 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
8002 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00008003 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008004 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008005 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008006 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008007 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008008 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008009}
8010
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008011CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008012
8013size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00008014 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8015 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8016 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8017 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8018 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8019 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8020 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8021 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8022 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8023 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8024 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8025 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8026 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8027 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008028}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008029
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008030/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8031/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8032/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8033/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8034QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8035 unsigned Signed) const {
8036 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8037 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8038 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8039 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8040 return QualTy;
8041}
8042
8043/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8044/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8045/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8046QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8047 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8048 switch (Ty) {
8049 case TargetInfo::Float:
8050 return FloatTy;
8051 case TargetInfo::Double:
8052 return DoubleTy;
8053 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8054 return LongDoubleTy;
8055 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8056 return QualType();
8057 }
8058
8059 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8060}
8061
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008062void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8063 if (Number > 1)
8064 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008065}
8066
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008067unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8068 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8069 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8070 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008071}
8072
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008073void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8074 if (Number > 1)
8075 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8076}
8077
8078unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8079 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8080 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8081 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8082}
8083
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008084MangleNumberingContext &
8085ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008086 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8087 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8088 if (!MCtx)
8089 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8090 return *MCtx;
8091}
8092
8093MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8094 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008095}
8096
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008097void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8098 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8099}
8100
8101unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8102 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8103 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8104 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8105 return I->second;
8106}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008107
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008108APValue *
8109ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8110 bool MayCreate) {
8111 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8112 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8113 if (MayCreate)
8114 return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8115
8116 llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8117 MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008118 return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? nullptr : &I->second;
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008119}
8120
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008121bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8122 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8123 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8124 return false;
8125
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008126 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8127 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8128 return false;
8129
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008130 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8131 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8132 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8133 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8134 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8135 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8136 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8137}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008138
8139namespace {
8140
8141 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8142 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8143 ///
8144 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8145 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8146 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8147 ///
8148 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8149 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8150
8151 public:
8152 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8153 ///
8154 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8155 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8156 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8157 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8158 return Visitor.Parents;
8159 }
8160
8161 private:
8162 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8163
8164 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8165 }
8166
8167 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8168 return true;
8169 }
8170 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8171 return true;
8172 }
8173 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8174 // are not triggered during data recursion.
8175 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8176 return false;
8177 }
8178
8179 template <typename T>
8180 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008181 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008182 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008183 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008184 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8185 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8186 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8187 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8188 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8189 // new matches.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008190 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8191 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8192 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8193 // do not have pointer identity.
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008194 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[Node];
8195 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
8196 NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008197 } else {
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008198 if (NodeOrVector.template is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8199 auto *Node =
8200 NodeOrVector.template get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
8201 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(1, *Node);
8202 NodeOrVector = Vector;
8203 delete Node;
8204 }
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008205 assert(NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>());
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008206
8207 auto *Vector =
8208 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8209 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8210 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8211 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8212 // types.
8213 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8214 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8215 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8216 if (!Found)
8217 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008218 }
8219 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008220 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8221 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8222 ParentStack.pop_back();
8223 return Result;
8224 }
8225
8226 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8227 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8228 }
8229
8230 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8231 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8232 }
8233
8234 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8235 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8236
8237 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8238 };
8239
8240} // end namespace
8241
8242ASTContext::ParentVector
8243ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8244 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8245 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8246 "used in the parent map.");
8247 if (!AllParents) {
8248 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8249 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8250 AllParents.reset(
8251 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8252 }
8253 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8254 if (I == AllParents->end()) {
8255 return ParentVector();
8256 }
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008257 if (I->second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8258 return ParentVector(1, *I->second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>());
8259 }
8260 const auto &Parents = *I->second.get<ParentVector *>();
8261 return ParentVector(Parents.begin(), Parents.end());
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008262}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008263
8264bool
8265ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8266 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8267 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8268 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8269 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8270 return false;
8271 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8272 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8273 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008274 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008275 return false;
8276
8277 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8278 return false;
8279
8280 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8281 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8282 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8283 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8284 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8285 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8286 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8287 return false;
8288 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8289 return false;
8290 }
8291 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8292
8293}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00008294
8295// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
8296// doesn't include ASTContext.h
8297template
8298clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8299 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
8300clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8301 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
8302 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);